blob: c06943f6718edbd17b9c7088472a132e84d3e585 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall7d384dd2009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner418f6c72008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregor314b97f2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlssonb633c4e2009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000381
382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattner2085fd62009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000478 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000479 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000480 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
481 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000482 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000483 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000485 << D->getIdentifier();
486 return ExprError();
487 }
488 }
489 }
490 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000491
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000492 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000493
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000494 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
495 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
496 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregor0da76df2009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000497 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000498}
499
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000500/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
501/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
502/// actual member.
503///
504/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
505/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
506/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
507/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
508/// we found.
509///
510/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
511/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
512/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
513VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
514 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000515 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
516 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
517 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
518
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000519 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000520 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
521 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
522 do {
523 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000524 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000525 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000526 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000527 else {
528 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
529 break;
530 }
531 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000532 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000533 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534
535 return BaseObject;
536}
537
538Sema::OwningExprResult
539Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
540 FieldDecl *Field,
541 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
542 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
543 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000544 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000545 AnonFields);
546
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000547 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
548 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
549 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
550 // found via name lookup.
551 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000552 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000553 if (BaseObject) {
554 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
555 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000556 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000557 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000558 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000559 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000560 BaseQuals
561 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000562 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
563 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
564 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
565 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
566 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000567 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000568 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
569 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
570 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000571 BaseQuals
572 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000573 } else {
574 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
575 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
576 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000577 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
578 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000579 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000580 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000581 = Context.getTagDeclType(
582 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
583 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000584 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000585 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
586 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
587 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000588 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000589 MD->getThisType(Context),
590 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000591 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
592 }
593 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000594 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
595 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000596 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000597 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 }
599
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000600 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000601 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
602 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000603 }
604
605 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
606 // anonymous struct/union.
607 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000608 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
610 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
611 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
612 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000613 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
614 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
615
616 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
617 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
618 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
619 ResultQuals.removeConst();
620
621 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
622 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
623
624 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
625 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
626
627 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
628 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
629 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
630
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000631 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000632 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000633 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000634 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
635 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000636 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000637 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000638 }
639
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000640 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000641}
642
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000643/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
644/// possibly a list of template arguments.
645///
646/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
647/// DecomposeTemplateName.
648///
649/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
650/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
651/// some way.
652static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
653 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
654 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
655 DeclarationName &Name,
656 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
657 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
658 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
659 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
660 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
661
662 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
663 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
664 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
665 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
666 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
667
668 TemplateName TName =
669 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
670
671 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
672 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
673 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
674 } else {
675 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
676 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
677 TemplateArgs = 0;
678 }
679}
680
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000681/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
682/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
683/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000684static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000685 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
686 return false;
687
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000688 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
689 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
690 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
691 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
692 if (!BaseRT) return false;
693
694 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000695 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000696 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
697 return false;
698 }
699
700 return true;
701}
702
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000703/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
704/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
705static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000707
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000708 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
709 if (!DC) return true;
710
711 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
712 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
713
714 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
715 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
716
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000717 return false;
718}
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000719
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000720/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
721/// the prospective base classes.
722static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
723 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
724 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000725 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000726 return false;
727
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000728 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000729 if (!RD) return false;
730 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
731
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000732 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
733 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
734 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
735 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
736 if (!BaseRT) return false;
737
738 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
740 return false;
741 }
742
743 return true;
744}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000745
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000746enum IMAKind {
747 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
748 IMA_Static,
749
750 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
751 IMA_Mixed,
752
753 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
754 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
755 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
756
757 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
758 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
759 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
760
761 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
762 IMA_Instance,
763
764 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
765 IMA_Unresolved,
766
767 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
768 /// context is not an instance method.
769 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
770
771 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
772 /// non-class context.
773 IMA_AnonymousMember,
774
775 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
776 /// context is not an instance method.
777 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
778
779 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
780 /// class.
781 IMA_Error_Unrelated
782};
783
784/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
785/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
786/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
787/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
788/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
789/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
790static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
791 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000792 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000793
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000794 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000795 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000796 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
797 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000798
799 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
800 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
801
802 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
803 bool hasNonInstance = false;
804 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
805 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000806 NamedDecl *D = *I;
807 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000808 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
809
810 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
811 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
812 // that's a special case.
813 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
814 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
815 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
816 }
817 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
818 }
819 else
820 hasNonInstance = true;
821 }
822
823 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
824 // member reference.
825 if (Classes.empty())
826 return IMA_Static;
827
828 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
829 // an implicit member reference.
830 if (isStaticContext)
831 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
832
833 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
834 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
835 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
836 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000837 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000838 Classes))
839 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
840
841 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
842}
843
844/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
845static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
846 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
847 const LookupResult &R) {
848 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
849 SourceRange Range(Loc);
850 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
851
852 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
853 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
854 if (MD->isStatic()) {
855 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
856 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
857 << Range << R.getLookupName();
858 return;
859 }
860 }
861
862 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
863 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
864 return;
865 }
866
867 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000868}
869
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000870/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
871///
872/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000873bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
874 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000875 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
876
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000877 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000878 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000879 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
880 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000881 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000882 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000883 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
884 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000885
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000886 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
887 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
888 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
889 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000890 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000891 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000892 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
893 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
894
895 if (!R.empty()) {
896 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
897 R.suppressDiagnostics();
898
899 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
900 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
901 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
902 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
903
904 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
905 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
906 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000907 if (isInstance) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000908 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000909 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000910
911 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
912 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
913 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
914 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
915 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
916 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(R.getNameLoc(),
917 DepThisType, false);
918 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
919 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
920 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
921 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
922 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
923 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
924 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL, Name,
925 R.getNameLoc(), &TList);
926 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
927 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000928 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000929 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000930
931 // Do we really want to note all of these?
932 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
933 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
934
935 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
936 return false;
937 }
938 }
939 }
940
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000941 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000942 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000943 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000944 if (!R.empty()) {
945 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
946 if (SS.isEmpty())
947 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
948 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
949 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
950 else
951 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
952 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
953 << SS.getRange()
954 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
955 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
956 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
957 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
958 << ND->getDeclName();
959
960 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
961 return false;
962 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000963
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000964 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
965 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
966 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
967 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
968 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
969 // to recover well anyway.
970 if (SS.isEmpty())
971 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
972 else
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
974 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
975 << SS.getRange();
976
977 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
978 return true;
979 }
980 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000981 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000982 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000983 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000984 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000985 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000986 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000987 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
988 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000989 return true;
990 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000991 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000992 }
993
994 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
995 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
996 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
997 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
998 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
999 << SS.getRange();
1000 return true;
1001 }
1002
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001003 // Give up, we can't recover.
1004 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1005 return true;
1006}
1007
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001008Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001009 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001010 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1011 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1012 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1013 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1014 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1015
1016 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001017 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001018
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001019 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001020
1021 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1022 DeclarationName Name;
1023 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1024 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001025 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1026 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001027
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001028 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001029
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001030 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1031 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001032 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1033 // (note: handled after lookup)
1034 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1035 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1036 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001037 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1038 // names a dependent type.
1039 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1040 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001041 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1042 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1043 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001044 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001045 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001046 TemplateArgs);
1047 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001048
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001049 // Perform the required lookup.
1050 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1051 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001052 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1053 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1054 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1055 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1056 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001057 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1058 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1059 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001060 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001061 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1062 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001063
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001064 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1065 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001066 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1067 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001068 if (E.isInvalid())
1069 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001070
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001071 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1072 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001073 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001074 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001075
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001076 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1077 return ExprError();
1078
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001079 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1080 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001081 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001082
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001083 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001084 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001085 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1086 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1087 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1088 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1089 }
1090
1091 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1092 // call, diagnose the problem.
1093 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001094 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001095 return ExprError();
1096
1097 assert(!R.empty() &&
1098 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001099
1100 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1101 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001102 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001103 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1104 R.clear();
1105 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1106 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1107 return move(E);
1108 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001109 }
1110 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001111
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001112 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1113 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1114
1115 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001116 // Warn about constructs like:
1117 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1118 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001119 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1120 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001121 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattner966c78b2010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001122 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001123 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001124 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001125 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattner966c78b2010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001126 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1127 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001128 break;
1129 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001130
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001131 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1132 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001133 }
1134 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001135 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001136 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1137 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1138 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1139 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1140 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1141 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001142 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001143 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001144
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001145 QualType T = Func->getType();
1146 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001147 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001148 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1149 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001150 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001151 }
1152 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001153
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001154 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1155 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1156 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1157 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1158 // class member access expression.
1159 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1160 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001161 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001162 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001163 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1164 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001165 }
1166
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001167 if (TemplateArgs)
1168 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001169
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001170 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1171}
1172
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001173/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1174Sema::OwningExprResult
1175Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1176 LookupResult &R,
1177 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1178 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1179 case IMA_Instance:
1180 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1181
1182 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1183 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1184 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1185 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1186
1187 case IMA_Mixed:
1188 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1189 case IMA_Unresolved:
1190 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1191
1192 case IMA_Static:
1193 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1194 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1195 if (TemplateArgs)
1196 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1197 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1198
1199 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1200 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1201 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1202 return ExprError();
1203 }
1204
1205 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1206 return ExprError();
1207}
1208
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001209/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1210/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1211/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1212/// this path.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001213Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001214Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 DeclarationName Name,
1216 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1217 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001218 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001219 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1220
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001221 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001222 return ExprError();
1223
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001224 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1225 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1226
1227 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1228 return ExprError();
1229
1230 if (R.empty()) {
1231 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1232 return ExprError();
1233 }
1234
1235 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1236}
1237
1238/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1239/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1240/// additional lookup.
1241///
1242/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1243/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1244///
1245/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1246Sema::OwningExprResult
1247Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001248 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001249 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001250 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001251
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001252 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1253 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1254 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1255 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1256 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1257
1258 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1259 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1260 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001261 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001262
1263 bool LookForIvars;
1264 if (Lookup.empty())
1265 LookForIvars = true;
1266 else if (IsClassMethod)
1267 LookForIvars = false;
1268 else
1269 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1270 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001271 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001272 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001273 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001274 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1275 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1276 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1277 if (IsClassMethod)
1278 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1279 << IV->getDeclName());
1280
1281 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1282 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1283 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1284 return ExprError();
1285
1286 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1287 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1288 return ExprError();
1289
1290 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1291 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1292 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1293 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1294
1295 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1296 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1297 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1298 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001299 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001300 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1301 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1302 SelfName, false, false);
1303 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1304 return Owned(new (Context)
1305 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1306 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1307 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001308 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001309 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001310 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001311 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1312 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1313 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1314 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1315 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1316 }
1317 }
1318
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001319 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1320 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1321 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1322 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1323 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1324 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1325 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1326 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1327 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1328 }
1329 }
1330 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001331 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1332 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001333}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001334
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001335/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1336///
1337/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1338///
1339/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1340/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1341/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1342/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1343///
1344/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1345/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1346/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1347/// the class declaring the member.
1348///
1349/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1350/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1351/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001352bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001353Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1354 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001355 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001356 NamedDecl *Member) {
1357 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1358 if (!RD)
1359 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001360
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001361 QualType DestRecordType;
1362 QualType DestType;
1363 QualType FromRecordType;
1364 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1365 bool PointerConversions = false;
1366 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1367 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001368
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001369 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1370 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1371 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1372 PointerConversions = true;
1373 } else {
1374 DestType = DestRecordType;
1375 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001376 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001377 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1378 if (Method->isStatic())
1379 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001380
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001381 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1382 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001383
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001384 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1385 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1386 PointerConversions = true;
1387 } else {
1388 FromRecordType = FromType;
1389 DestType = DestRecordType;
1390 }
1391 } else {
1392 // No conversion necessary.
1393 return false;
1394 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001395
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001396 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1397 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001398
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001399 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1400 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1401 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001402
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001403 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1404 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1405
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001406 bool isLvalue
1407 = (From->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) && !PointerConversions;
1408
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001409 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001410 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001411 // class name.
1412 //
1413 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1414 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1415 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1416 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1417 //
1418 // class Base { public: int x; };
1419 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1420 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1421 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1422 //
1423 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1424 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1425 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1426 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001427 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001428 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1429 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1430 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1431
1432 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1433
1434 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1435 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1436 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1437 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001438 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001439 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001440 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001441 return true;
1442
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001443 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001444 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001445 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001446 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001447
1448 FromType = QType;
1449 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1450
1451 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1452 // we're done.
1453 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1454 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001455 }
1456 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001457
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001458 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001459
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001460 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1461 // down to the using declaration's type.
1462 //
1463 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1464 // class ever has member declarations.
1465 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1466 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1467 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1468 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1469
1470 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1471 // conversion is non-trivial.
1472 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1473 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001474 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001475 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001476 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001477 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001478
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001479 QualType UType = URecordType;
1480 if (PointerConversions)
1481 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001482 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001483 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001484 FromType = UType;
1485 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1486 }
1487
1488 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1489 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1490 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001491 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001492
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001493 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1494 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1495 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001496 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001497 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001498
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001499 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001500 isLvalue, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001501 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001502}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001503
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001504/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001505static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001506 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001507 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1508 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001509 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1510 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1511 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001512 if (SS.isSet()) {
1513 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1514 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001515 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001516
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001517 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001518 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001519}
1520
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001521/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1522/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1523/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1524/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001525Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001526Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1527 LookupResult &R,
1528 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1529 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001530 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1531
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001532 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001533
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001534 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1535 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001536 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001537 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001538 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001539 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001540 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001541
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001542 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1543 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001544 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1545 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001546 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1547 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001548 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1549 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1550 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1551 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001552 }
1553
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001554 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1555 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1556 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001557 SS,
1558 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1559 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001560}
1561
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001562bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001563 const LookupResult &R,
1564 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001565 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1566 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1567 return false;
1568
1569 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001570 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001571 return false;
1572
1573 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001574 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001575 return false;
1576
1577 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1578 // normal lookup:
1579 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1580 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1581
1582 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1583 // -- a declaration of a class member
1584 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1585 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001586 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001587 return false;
1588
1589 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1590 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1591 // using-declaration
1592 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1593 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1594 // turn off ADL anyway).
1595 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1596 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1597 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1598 return false;
1599
1600 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1601 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1602 // template
1603 // And also for builtin functions.
1604 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1605 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1606
1607 // But also builtin functions.
1608 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1609 return false;
1610 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1611 return false;
1612 }
1613
1614 return true;
1615}
1616
1617
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001618/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1619/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1620/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1621/// will in fact be used.
1622static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1623 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1624 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1625 return true;
1626 }
1627
1628 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1629 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1630 return true;
1631 }
1632
1633 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1634 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1635 return true;
1636 }
1637
1638 return false;
1639}
1640
1641Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001642Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001643 LookupResult &R,
1644 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001645 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1646 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001647 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001648 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001649
1650 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1651 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1652 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001653 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1654 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001655 return ExprError();
1656
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001657 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1658 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1659 // we've picked a target.
1660 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1661
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001662 bool Dependent
1663 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001664 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001665 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001666 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1667 SS.getRange(),
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001668 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001669 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1670 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001671
1672 return Owned(ULE);
1673}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001674
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001675
1676/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1677Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001678Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001679 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1680 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001681 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1682 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001683
1684 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1685 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001686
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001687 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1688 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1689 // a template argument list.
1690 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1691 << Template << SS.getRange();
1692 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1693 return ExprError();
1694 }
1695
1696 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1697 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1698 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001699 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001700 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001701 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001702 return ExprError();
1703 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001704
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001705 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1706 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1707 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1708 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001709 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001710 return ExprError();
1711
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001712 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1713 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001714 return ExprError();
1715
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001716 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1717 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1718 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1719 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001720 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001721 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1722 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1723 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001724 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001725 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001726 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1727 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1728 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1729 return ExprError();
1730 }
1731
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001732 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001733 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1734 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1735 return ExprError();
1736 }
1737
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001738 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001739 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001740 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001741 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001742 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001743 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1744 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001745 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001746
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001747 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001748 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001749 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1750 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001751 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001752 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1753 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1754 Expr *E = new (Context)
1755 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1756 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001757
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001758 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
1759 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001760 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001761 SourceLocation(),
1762 Owned(E));
1763 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
1764 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
1765 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1766 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1767 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001768 }
1769 }
1770 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001771 }
1772 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1773 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001774
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001775 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001776}
1777
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001778Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1779 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001780 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001781
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001782 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001783 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001784 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1785 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1786 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001787 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001788
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001789 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1790 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001791
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001792 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1793 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001794 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001795 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001796 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001797
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001798 QualType ResTy;
1799 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1800 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1801 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001802 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001803
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001804 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001805 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001806 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1807 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001808 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001809}
1810
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001811Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001812 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001813 bool Invalid = false;
1814 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1815 if (Invalid)
1816 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001817
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001818 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1819 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001820 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001821 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001822
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001823 QualType Ty;
1824 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1825 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1826 else if (Literal.isWide())
1827 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001828 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1829 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001830 else
1831 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001832
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001833 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1834 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001835 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001836}
1837
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001838Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1839 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001840 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1841 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001842 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001843 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001844 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001845 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001846 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001847
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001848 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001849 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1850 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001851 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001852
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001853 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001854 bool Invalid = false;
1855 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1856 if (Invalid)
1857 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001858
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001859 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001860 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1861 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001862 return ExprError();
1863
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001864 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001865
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001866 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001867 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001868 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001869 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001870 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001871 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001872 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001873 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001874
1875 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1876
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001877 using llvm::APFloat;
1878 APFloat Val(Format);
1879
1880 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001881
1882 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1883 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1884 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1885 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001886 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001887 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001888 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001889 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001890 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1891 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001892 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001893 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1894 }
1895
1896 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1897 << Ty
1898 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1899 }
1900
1901 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattner001d64d2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001902 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001903
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001904 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001905 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001906 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001907 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001908
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001909 // long long is a C99 feature.
1910 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001911 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001912 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1913
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001914 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001915 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001917 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1918 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1919 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001920 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1921 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001922 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001923 } else {
1924 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1925 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001926
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001927 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1928 // be an unsigned int.
1929 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1930
1931 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001932 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001933 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1934 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001935 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001936
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001937 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1938 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1939 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1940 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001941 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001942 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001943 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001944 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001945 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001946 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001947
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001948 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001949 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001950 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001951
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001952 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1953 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1954 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1955 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001956 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001957 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001958 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001959 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001960 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001961 }
1962
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001963 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001964 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001965 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001966
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001967 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1968 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1969 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1970 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001971 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001972 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001973 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001974 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001975 }
1976 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001977
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001978 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1979 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001980 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001981 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001982 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001983 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001984 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001985
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001986 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1987 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001988 }
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001989 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001990 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001991
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001992 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1993 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001994 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001995 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001996
1997 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001998}
1999
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002000Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2001 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002002 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002003 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002004 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002005}
2006
2007/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2008/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002009bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002010 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2011 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2012 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002013 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2014 return false;
2015
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002016 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2017 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2018 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2019 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2020 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2021 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2022
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002023 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002024 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002025 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002026 if (isSizeof)
2027 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2028 return false;
2029 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002030
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002031 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002032 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002033 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2034 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002035 return false;
2036 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002037
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002038 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002039 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2040 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002041 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002042
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002043 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002044 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002045 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002046 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2047 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002048 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002049
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002050 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2051 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2052 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2053 return true;
2054 }
2055
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002056 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002057}
2058
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002059bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2060 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2061 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002062
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002063 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002064 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2065 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002066
2067 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2068 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2069 return false;
2070
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002071 if (E->getBitField()) {
2072 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2073 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002074 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002075
2076 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2077 // bit-field.
2078 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002079 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002080 return false;
2081
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002082 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2083}
2084
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002085/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002086Action::OwningExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002087Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002088 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002089 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002090 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002091 return ExprError();
2092
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002093 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002094
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002095 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2096 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2097 return ExprError();
2098
2099 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002100 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002101 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2102 R.getEnd()));
2103}
2104
2105/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2106/// operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002107Action::OwningExprResult
2108Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002109 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2110 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2111 bool isInvalid = false;
2112 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2113 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2114 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2115 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002116 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002117 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2118 isInvalid = true;
2119 } else {
2120 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2121 }
2122
2123 if (isInvalid)
2124 return ExprError();
2125
2126 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2127 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2128 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2129 R.getEnd()));
2130}
2131
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002132/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2133/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2134/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002135Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002136Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2137 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002138 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002139 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002140
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002141 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002142 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2143 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2144 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002145 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002146
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002147 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2148 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2149 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2150
2151 if (Result.isInvalid())
2152 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2153
2154 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002155}
2156
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002157QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002158 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2159 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002160
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002161 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002162 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002163 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002164
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002165 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2166 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2167 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002168
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002169 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002170 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2171 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002172 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002173}
2174
2175
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002176
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002177Action::OwningExprResult
2178Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2179 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002180 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2181 switch (Kind) {
2182 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2183 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2184 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2185 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002186
Eli Friedmane4216e92009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002187 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002188}
2189
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002190Action::OwningExprResult
2191Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2192 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002193 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2194 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2195
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002196 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2197 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002198
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002199 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002200 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2201 Base.release();
2202 Idx.release();
2203 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2204 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2205 }
2206
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002207 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002208 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002209 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2210 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2211 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002212 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002213 }
2214
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002215 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2216}
2217
2218
2219Action::OwningExprResult
2220Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2221 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2222 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2223 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2224
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002225 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002226 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2227 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2228 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002229
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002230 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002231
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002232 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002233 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002234 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002235 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002236 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2237 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002238 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2239 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2240 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2241 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002242 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002243 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2244 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002245 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002246 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002247 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002248 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2249 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002250 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002251 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002252 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002253 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2254 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2255 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002256 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002257 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002258 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2259 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2260 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2261 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002262 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002263 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002264 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002265
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002266 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2267 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002268 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2269 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002270 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002271 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2272 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2273 // force the promotion here.
2274 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2275 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002276 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2277 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002278 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2279
2280 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2281 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002282 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002283 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2284 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2285 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2286 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002287 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2288 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002289 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2290
2291 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2292 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002293 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002294 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002295 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2296 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002297 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002298 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002299 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2300 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002301 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2302 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002303
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002304 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002305 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2306 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002307 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2308
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002309 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002310 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2311 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002312 // incomplete types are not object types.
2313 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2314 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2315 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2316 return ExprError();
2317 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002318
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002319 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002320 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002321 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2322 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002323 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002324
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002325 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002326 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002327 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2328 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2329 return ExprError();
2330 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002331
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002332 Base.release();
2333 Idx.release();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002334 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002335 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002336}
2337
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002338QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002339CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002340 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002341 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002342 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2343 // see FIXME there.
2344 //
2345 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2346 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002347 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002348
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002349 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002350 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002351
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002352 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002353 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2354 // to be selected.
2355 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002356
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002357 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2358 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002359 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002360
2361 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2362 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002363 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002364 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2365 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002366 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002367 do
2368 compStr++;
2369 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002370 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002371 do
2372 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002373 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002374 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002375
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002376 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002377 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2378 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002379 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2380 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002381 return QualType();
2382 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002383
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002384 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2385 // operates on.
2386 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002387 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002388
2389 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002390 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002391
2392 while (*compStr) {
2393 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2394 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2395 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2396 return QualType();
2397 }
2398 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002399 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002400
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002401 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002402 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002403 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002404 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002405 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002406 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002407 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002408 if (HexSwizzle)
2409 CompSize--;
2410
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002411 if (CompSize == 1)
2412 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002413
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002414 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002415 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002416 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2417 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2418 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2419 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002420 }
2421 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002422}
2423
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002424static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002425 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002426 const Selector &Sel,
2427 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002428
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002429 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002430 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002431 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002432 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002433
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002434 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2435 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002436 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002437 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002438 return D;
2439 }
2440 return 0;
2441}
2442
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002443static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002444 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002445 const Selector &Sel,
2446 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002447 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2448 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002449 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002450 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002451 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002452 GDecl = PD;
2453 break;
2454 }
2455 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002456 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002457 GDecl = OMD;
2458 break;
2459 }
2460 }
2461 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002462 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002463 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2464 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002465 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002466 if (GDecl)
2467 return GDecl;
2468 }
2469 }
2470 return GDecl;
2471}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002472
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002473Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002474Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2475 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002476 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2477 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2478 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2479 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2480 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2481
2482 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2483 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2484 //
2485 // T* t;
2486 // t.f;
2487 //
2488 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2489 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2490 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2491 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002492 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002493 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2494 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002495 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002496 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002497 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002498 return ExprError();
2499 }
2500 }
2501
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002502 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002503 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002504
2505 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2506 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002507 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002508 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2509 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2510 SS.getRange(),
2511 FirstQualifierInScope,
2512 Name, NameLoc,
2513 TemplateArgs));
2514}
2515
2516/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2517/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2518/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2519static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2520 Expr *BaseExpr,
2521 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002522 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002523 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002524 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2525 // diagnostics.
2526 if (!BaseExpr)
2527 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002528
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002529 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2530 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002531}
2532
2533// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2534// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2535// type. The restriction here is:
2536//
2537// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2538// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2539// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2540//
2541// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2542// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2543// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2544// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2545bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2546 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002547 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002548 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002549 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2550 if (!BaseRT) {
2551 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2552 // dependent.
2553 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2554 return false;
2555 }
2556 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002557
2558 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002559 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2560 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002561 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002562 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002563
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002564 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2565 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2566 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2567 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2568
2569 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2570 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2571
2572 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2573 return false;
2574 }
2575
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002576 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002577 return true;
2578}
2579
2580static bool
2581LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2582 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002583 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2584 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002585 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2586 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002587 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002588 << BaseRange))
2589 return true;
2590
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002591 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2592 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2593 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2594
2595 bool MOUS;
2596 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2597 return false;
2598 }
2599
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002600 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2601 if (SS.isSet()) {
2602 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2603 // nested-name-specifier.
2604 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2605
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002606 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002607 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2608 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2609 return true;
2610 }
2611
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002612 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002613
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002614 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2615 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2616 << DC << SS.getRange();
2617 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002618 }
2619 }
2620
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002621 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2622 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002623
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002624 if (!R.empty())
2625 return false;
2626
2627 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2628 // for typos.
2629 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002630 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002631 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002632 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2633 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2634 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002635 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2636 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002637 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2638 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2639 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002640 return false;
2641 } else {
2642 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002643 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002644 }
2645
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002646 return false;
2647}
2648
2649Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002650Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002651 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002652 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002653 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2654 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2655 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2656 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2657
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002658 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2659 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002660 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002661 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2662 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2663 Name, NameLoc,
2664 TemplateArgs);
2665
2666 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002667
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002668 // Implicit member accesses.
2669 if (!Base) {
2670 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2671 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2672 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2673 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002674 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002675 return ExprError();
2676
2677 // Explicit member accesses.
2678 } else {
2679 OwningExprResult Result =
2680 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002681 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002682
2683 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2684 Owned(Base);
2685 return ExprError();
2686 }
2687
2688 if (Result.get())
2689 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002690
2691 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2692 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002693 }
2694
Sebastian Redl0aa866f2010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002695 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002696 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2697 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002698}
2699
2700Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002701Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2702 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2703 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002704 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002705 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002706 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2707 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002708 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002709 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002710 if (IsArrow) {
2711 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2712 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2713 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002714 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002715
2716 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2717 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2718 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2719 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2720
2721 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002722 return ExprError();
2723
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002724 if (R.empty()) {
2725 // Rederive where we looked up.
2726 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2727 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2728 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002729
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002730 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002731 << MemberName << DC
2732 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002733 return ExprError();
2734 }
2735
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002736 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2737 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2738 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2739 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2740 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2741 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2742 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2743 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2744 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2745 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002746 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002747 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002748 return ExprError();
2749
2750 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2751 // result.
2752 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002753 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002754 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002755 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002756 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002757
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002758 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2759 // pick a member.
2760 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2761
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002762 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2763 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2764 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002765 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2766 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002767 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2768 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002769 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002770
2771 return Owned(MemExpr);
2772 }
2773
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002774 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002775 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002776 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2777
2778 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2779
2780 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2781 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2782 // error cases.
2783 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2784 return ExprError();
2785
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002786 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2787 if (!BaseExpr) {
2788 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002789 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002790 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2791
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002792 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2793 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2794 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2795 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002796 }
2797
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002798 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2799 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2800 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2801 // explicitly qualified.
2802 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2803 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2804 }
2805
2806 // Check the use of this member.
2807 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2808 Owned(BaseExpr);
2809 return ExprError();
2810 }
2811
2812 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2813 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2814 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002815 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2816 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002817 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2818 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2819
2820 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2821 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2822 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2823 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2824 else {
2825 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2826 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2827 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2828
2829 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2830 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2831
2832 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2833 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2834 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2835 }
2836
2837 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002838 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002839 return ExprError();
2840 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002841 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002842 }
2843
2844 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2845 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2846 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002847 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002848 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2849 }
2850
2851 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2852 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2853 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002854 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002855 MemberFn->getType()));
2856 }
2857
2858 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2859 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2860 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002861 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002862 }
2863
2864 Owned(BaseExpr);
2865
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002866 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002867 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002868 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2869 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2870 else
2871 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2872 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002873
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002874 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2875 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002876 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002877 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002878}
2879
2880/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2881/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2882/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2883/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2884/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2885/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2886/// an ordinary member expression.
2887///
2888/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2889/// fixed for ObjC++.
2890Sema::OwningExprResult
2891Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002892 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002893 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002894 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002895 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002896
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002897 // Perform default conversions.
2898 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002899
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002900 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002901 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2902
2903 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2904 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002905
2906 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002907 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002908 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2909 // call, and continue on.
2910 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2911 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2912 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2913 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2914 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002915 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2916 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002917 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2918 ->isRecordType()))) {
2919 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2920 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2921 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002922 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002923
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002924 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002925 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002926 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00002927 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002928 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002929 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002930
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002931 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2932 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2933 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2934 }
2935 }
2936 }
2937
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002938 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2939 // use that.
2940 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002941 if (IsArrow) {
2942 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2943 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2944 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002945 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002946 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002947 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2948 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002949 }
2950 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002951 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2952 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2953 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2954 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002955 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002956 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002957 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002958
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002959 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2960 // use that.
2961 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2962 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2963 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2964 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2965 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2966 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2967 }
2968 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002969
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002970 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002971
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002972 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002973 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002974 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2975 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2976 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2977 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2978 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2979 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2980 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2981 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2982 // Check the use of this method.
2983 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2984 return ExprError();
2985 }
2986 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2987 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2988 Selector SetterSel =
2989 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2990 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2991 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2992 if (!Setter) {
2993 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2994 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002995 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002996 }
2997 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2998 if (!Setter)
2999 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003000
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003001 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3002 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003003
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003004 if (Getter || Setter) {
3005 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003006
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003007 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003008 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003009 else
3010 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3011 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3012 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003013 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003014 PType,
3015 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3016 }
3017 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3018 << MemberName << BaseType);
3019 }
3020 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003021
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003022 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3023 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3024 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003025 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003026 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003027
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003028 if (IsArrow) {
3029 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003030 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003031 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3032 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003033 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3034 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3035 // struct MyRecord foo;
3036 // foo->bar
3037 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3038 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3039 // by now.
3040 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3041 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003042 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003043 IsArrow = false;
3044 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003045 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3046 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3047 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003048 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003049 } else {
3050 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3051 // type *foo;
3052 // foo.bar
3053 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3054 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3055 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3056 // the appropriate pointer type
3057 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3058 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3059 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3060 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3061 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003062 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003063 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3064 IsArrow = true;
3065 }
3066 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003067 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003068
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003069 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003070 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003071 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003072 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003073 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003074 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003075 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003076
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003077 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3078 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003079 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003080 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003081 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003082 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3083 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3084 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3085 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003086 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3087
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003088 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003089 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003090
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003091 if (!IV) {
3092 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3093 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3094 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003095 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003096 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003097 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003098 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3099 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003100 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3101 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003102 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003103 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003104 } else {
3105 Res.clear();
3106 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003107 }
3108 }
3109
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003110 if (IV) {
3111 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3112 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3113 // error cases.
3114 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3115 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003116
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003117 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3118 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3119 return ExprError();
3120 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3121 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3122 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3123 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3124 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3125 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3126 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3127 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3128 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3129 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3130 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3131 // AST for a function decl.
3132 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003133 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003134 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3135 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3136 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3137 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3138 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3139 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003140
3141 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3142 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003143 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003144 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003145 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003146 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3147 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003148 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003149 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003150 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003151
3152 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3153 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003154 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003155 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003156 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003157 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003158 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003159 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003160 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003161 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003162 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3163 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003164 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003165 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003166
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003167 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003168 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003169 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3170 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3171 // Check the use of this declaration
3172 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3173 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003174
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003175 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3176 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3177 }
3178 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3179 // Check the use of this method.
3180 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3181 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003182
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003183 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003184 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor04badcf2010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003185 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3186 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003187 }
3188 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003189
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003190 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003191 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003192 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003193
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003194 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3195 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003196 if (!IsArrow)
3197 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3198 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003199 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003200
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003201 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003202 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003203 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3204 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003205 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003206 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003207 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003208
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003209 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003210 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003211 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003212 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3213 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003214 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003215 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003216 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003217 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003218
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003219 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3220 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3221
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003222 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003223}
3224
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003225/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3226/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3227/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3228/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3229/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3230///
3231/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3232/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3233/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3234/// only be called
3235/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3236/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3237/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3238Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3239 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3240 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003241 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003242 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3243 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3244 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3245 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3246 return ExprError();
3247
3248 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3249
3250 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3251 DeclarationName Name;
3252 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3253 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3254 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3255 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3256
3257 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3258
3259 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3260 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3261 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3262
3263 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3264 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3265
3266 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3267 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003268 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3269 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003270 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003271 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3272 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3273 Name, NameLoc,
3274 TemplateArgs);
3275 } else {
3276 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003277 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3278 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003279
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003280 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3281 Owned(Base);
3282 return ExprError();
3283 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003284
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003285 if (Result.get()) {
3286 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3287 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3288 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3289 // call now.
3290 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3291 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
3292 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003293
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003294 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003295 }
3296
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003297 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003298 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3299 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003300 }
3301
3302 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003303}
3304
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003305Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3306 FunctionDecl *FD,
3307 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3308 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3309 Diag (CallLoc,
3310 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3311 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003312 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003313 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3314 } else {
3315 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3316 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3317
3318 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor525f96c2010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003319 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3320 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003321
Douglas Gregor24bae922010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003322 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3323 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3324 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3325 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003326
John McCallce3ff2b2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003327 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003328 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003329 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003330
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003331 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3332 InitializedEntity Entity
3333 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3334 InitializationKind Kind
3335 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3336 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3337 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3338
3339 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003340 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003341 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3342 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003343 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003344
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003345 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003346 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003347 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003348 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003349
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003350 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3351 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3352 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003353 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3354 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson337cba42009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003355 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3356 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003357 }
3358
3359 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003360 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003361}
3362
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003363/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3364/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3365/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3366/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3367/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3368/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003369bool
3370Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003371 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003372 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003373 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3374 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003375 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003376 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3377 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003378 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003379
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003380 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3381 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3382 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3383 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3384 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003385 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003386 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003387 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003388 }
3389
3390 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3391 // them.
3392 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3393 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3394 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3395 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003396 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003397 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003398 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3399 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3400 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003401 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003402 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003403 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003404 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003405 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003406 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003407 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3408 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3409 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3410 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3411 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003412 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003413 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003414 if (Invalid)
3415 return true;
3416 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3417 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3418 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003419
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003420 return false;
3421}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003422
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003423bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3424 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3425 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3426 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3427 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3428 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003429 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003430 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3431 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3432 bool Invalid = false;
3433 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3434 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3435 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3436 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003437 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003438 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003439 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003440
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003441 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003442 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3443 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003444
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003445 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3446 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003447 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003448 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003449 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003450
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003451 // Pass the argument
3452 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3453 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3454 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003455
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003456
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003457 InitializedEntity Entity =
3458 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3459 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3460 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3461 SourceLocation(),
3462 Owned(Arg));
3463 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3464 return true;
3465
3466 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003467 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003468 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003469
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003470 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003471 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003472 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3473 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003474
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003475 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003476 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003477 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003478 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003479
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003480 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003481 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003482 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003483 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003484 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003485 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003486 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003487 }
3488 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003489 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003490}
3491
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003492/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003493/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3494/// locations.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003495Action::OwningExprResult
3496Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3497 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003498 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003499 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003500
3501 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3502 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003503
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003504 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003505 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner74c469f2007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003506 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003507
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003508 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003509 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3510 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3511 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3512 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3513 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003514 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003515 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3516 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003517
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003518 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3519 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003520
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003521 NumArgs = 0;
3522 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003523
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003524 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3525 RParenLoc));
3526 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003527
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003528 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003529 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003530 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3531 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003532 bool Dependent = false;
3533 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3534 Dependent = true;
3535 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3536 Dependent = true;
3537
3538 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003539 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003540 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3541
3542 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3543 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3544 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3545 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3546
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003547 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3548
3549 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3550 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3551 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3552 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3553 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3554 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3555 // method template.
3556 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003557 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3558 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003559 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003560
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003561 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3562 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003563 }
3564
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003565 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003566 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003567 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003568 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003569 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3570 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003571 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003572
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003573 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003574 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003575 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3576 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003577 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3578 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003579 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003580
3581 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3582 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003583 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3584 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003585
3586 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3587 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003588 TheCall.get(), 0))
3589 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003590
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003591 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003592 RParenLoc))
3593 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003594
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003595 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3596 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003597 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003598 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3599 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003600 }
3601 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003602 }
3603
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003604 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003605 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003606 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003607
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003608 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003609 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3610 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003611 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003612 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003613 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003614
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003615 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3616 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3617 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3618
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003619 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3620}
3621
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003622/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3623/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003624/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3625/// block-pointer type.
3626///
3627/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3628Sema::OwningExprResult
3629Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3630 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3631 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3632 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3633 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3634
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003635 // Promote the function operand.
3636 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3637
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003638 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3639 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003640 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3641 Args, NumArgs,
3642 Context.BoolTy,
3643 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003644
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003645 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3646 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3647 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3648 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003649 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003650 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003651 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3652 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003653 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003654 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003655 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003656 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003657 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003658 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003659 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3660 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3661
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003662 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003663 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003664 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3665 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003666 return ExprError();
3667
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003668 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003669 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003670
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003671 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003672 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003673 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003674 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003675 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003676 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003677
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003678 if (FDecl) {
3679 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3680 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3681 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003682 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003683 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003684 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003685 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3686 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3687 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3688 }
3689 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003690 }
3691
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003692 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003693 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3694 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3695 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003696 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3697 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003698 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3699 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003700 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003701 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003702 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003703 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003704
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003705 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3706 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003707 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3708 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003709
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003710 // Check for sentinels
3711 if (NDecl)
3712 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003713
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003714 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003715 if (FDecl) {
3716 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3717 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003718
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003719 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003720 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3721 } else if (NDecl) {
3722 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3723 return ExprError();
3724 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003725
Anders Carlssonec74c592009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003726 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003727}
3728
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003729Action::OwningExprResult
3730Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3731 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003732 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003733 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003734 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003735
3736 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3737 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3738 if (!TInfo)
3739 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3740
3741 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3742}
3743
3744Action::OwningExprResult
3745Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3746 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3747 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003748 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003749
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003750 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003751 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003752 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3753 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003754 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3755 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003756 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003757 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003758 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003759 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003760
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003761 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003762 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003763 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003764 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003765 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003766 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3767 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3768 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3769 &literalType);
3770 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003771 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003772 InitExpr.release();
3773 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003774
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003775 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003776 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003777 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003778 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003779 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003780
3781 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003782
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003783 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003784 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003785}
3786
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003787Action::OwningExprResult
3788Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003789 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3790 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3791 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003792
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003793 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003794 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003795
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003796 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3797 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003798 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003799 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003800}
3801
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003802static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3803 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003804 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003805 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3806
3807 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3808 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003809 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3810 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahaniana7fa7cd2009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003811 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003812 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3813 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3814 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003815
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003816 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3817 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3818 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3819 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3820 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3821 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3822 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3823 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003824
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003825 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3826 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3827 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3828 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3829 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3830 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003831
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003832 // FIXME: Assert here.
3833 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3834 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3835}
3836
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003837/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003838bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003839 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003840 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003841 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003842 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003843 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3844 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003845
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003846 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003847
3848 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3849 // type needs to be scalar.
3850 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3851 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003852 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3853 return false;
3854 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003855
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003856 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003857 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003858 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3859 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003860 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003861 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3862 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003863 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003864 return false;
3865 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003866
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003867 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003868 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003869 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003870 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003871 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003872 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003873 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003874 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003875 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3876 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3877 break;
3878 }
3879 }
3880 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3881 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3882 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003883 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003884 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003885 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003886
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003887 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3888 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3889 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3890 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003891
3892 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003893 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003894 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3895 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003896 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003897 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003898
3899 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003900 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003901
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003902 if (castType->isVectorType())
3903 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3904 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3905 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3906
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003907 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3908 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003909
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003910 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003911 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003912 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003913 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003914 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3915 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3916 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3917 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003918 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003919 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3920 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3921 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003922 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003923
3924 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003925 return false;
3926}
3927
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003928bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3929 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003930 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003931
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003932 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003933 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003934 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003935 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003936 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003937 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003938 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003939 } else
3940 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003941 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003942 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003943
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003944 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003945 return false;
3946}
3947
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003948bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003949 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003950 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003951
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003952 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003953
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003954 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3955 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003956 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3957 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3958 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3959 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003960 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003961 return false;
3962 }
3963
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003964 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003965 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3966 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003967 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3968 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3969 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3970 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003971
3972 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3973 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3974 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003975
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003976 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003977 return false;
3978}
3979
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003980Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003981Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003982 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3983 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3984 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003985
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003986 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3987 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3988 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003989 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003990
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003991 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003992 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003993 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003994 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3995 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003996
3997 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3998}
3999
4000Action::OwningExprResult
4001Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4002 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4003 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4004
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004005 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004006 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004007 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004008 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004009 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004010
Douglas Gregord6e44a32010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004011 Op.release();
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004012 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(
4013 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004014 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssoncdb61972009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004015 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004016}
4017
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004018/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4019/// of comma binary operators.
4020Action::OwningExprResult
4021Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4022 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4023 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4024 if (!E)
4025 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004026
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004027 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004028
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004029 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4030 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4031 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004032
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004033 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4034}
4035
4036Action::OwningExprResult
4037Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4038 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004039 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004040 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004041 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004042 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004043
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004044 // Check for an altivec literal,
4045 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004046 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4047 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4048 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4049 return ExprError();
4050 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004051 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4052 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4053 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4054 }
4055 else
4056 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4057 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004058
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004059 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4060 // then handle it as such.
4061 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004062 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4063 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4064 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4065
4066 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4067 // braces instead of the original commas.
4068 Op.release();
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004069 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4070 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004071 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4072 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004073 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004074 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004075 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004076 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4077 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004078 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004079 }
4080}
4081
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004082Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004083 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004084 MultiExprArg Val,
4085 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004086 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4087 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004088 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4089 Expr *expr;
4090 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4091 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4092 else
4093 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004094 return Owned(expr);
4095}
4096
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004097/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4098/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004099/// C99 6.5.15
4100QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4101 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004102 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4103 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4104 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4105
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004106 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4107 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4108 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4109 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4110 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4111 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004112
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004113 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004114 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4115 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4116 << CondTy;
4117 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004118 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004119
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004120 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004121 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4122 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004123
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004124 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4125 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004126 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4127 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4128 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004129 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004130
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004131 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4132 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004133 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4134 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004135 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004136 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004137 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004138 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004139 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004140 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004141
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004142 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004143 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004144 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4145 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4146 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4147 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4148 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4149 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4150 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004151 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4152 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004153 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004154 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004155 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4156 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004157 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004158 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004159 // promote the null to a pointer.
4160 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004161 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004162 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004163 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004164 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004165 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004166 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004167 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004168
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004169 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4170 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4171 QuestionLoc);
4172 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4173 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004174
4175
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004176 // Handle block pointer types.
4177 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4178 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4179 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4180 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004181 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4182 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004183 return destType;
4184 }
4185 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004186 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004187 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004188 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004189 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4190 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4191 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004192 return LHSTy;
4193 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004194 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004195 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4196 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004197
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004198 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4199 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004200 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004201 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004202 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4203 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4204 // to get a consistent AST.
4205 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004206 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4207 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004208 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004209 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004210 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004211 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4212 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004213 return LHSTy;
4214 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004215
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004216 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4217 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4218 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004219 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4220 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004221
4222 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4223 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4224 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004225 QualType destPointee
4226 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004227 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004228 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4229 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4230 // Promote to void*.
4231 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004232 return destType;
4233 }
4234 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004235 QualType destPointee
4236 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004237 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004238 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004239 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004240 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004241 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004242 return destType;
4243 }
4244
4245 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4246 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4247 return LHSTy;
4248 }
4249 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4250 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4251 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4252 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4253 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4254 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4255 // to get a consistent AST.
4256 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004257 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4258 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004259 return incompatTy;
4260 }
4261 // The pointer types are compatible.
4262 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4263 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4264 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4265 // type.
4266 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4267 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004268 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4269 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004270 return LHSTy;
4271 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004272
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004273 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4274 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4275 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4276 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004277 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004278 return RHSTy;
4279 }
4280 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4281 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4282 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004283 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004284 return LHSTy;
4285 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004286
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004287 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004288 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4289 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004290 return QualType();
4291}
4292
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004293/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4294/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4295QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4296 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4297 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4298 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004299
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004300 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4301 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4302 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4303 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4304 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4305 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4306 return LHSTy;
4307 }
4308 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4309 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4310 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4311 return RHSTy;
4312 }
4313 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4314 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4315 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4316 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4317 return LHSTy;
4318 }
4319 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4320 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4321 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4322 return RHSTy;
4323 }
4324 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4325 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4326 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4327 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4328 return LHSTy;
4329 }
4330 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4331 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4332 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4333 return RHSTy;
4334 }
4335 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4336 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004337
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004338 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4339 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4340 return LHSTy;
4341 }
4342 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4343 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4344 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004345
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004346 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4347 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4348 // type. This allows
4349 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4350 // where B is a subclass of A.
4351 //
4352 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4353 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4354 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4355 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004356
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004357 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4358 // It could return the composite type.
4359 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4360 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4361 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4362 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4363 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4364 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4365 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4366 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4367 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4368 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4369 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4370 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4371 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4372 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004373 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004374 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4375 ;
4376 else {
4377 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4378 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4379 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4380 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4381 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4382 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4383 return incompatTy;
4384 }
4385 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4386 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4387 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4388 return compositeType;
4389 }
4390 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4391 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4392 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4393 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4394 QualType destPointee
4395 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4396 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4397 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4398 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4399 // Promote to void*.
4400 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4401 return destType;
4402 }
4403 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4404 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4405 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4406 QualType destPointee
4407 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4408 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4409 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4410 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4411 // Promote to void*.
4412 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4413 return destType;
4414 }
4415 return QualType();
4416}
4417
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004418/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004419/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004420Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4421 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4422 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4423 ExprArg RHS) {
4424 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4425 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004426
4427 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4428 // was the condition.
4429 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4430 if (isLHSNull)
4431 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004432
4433 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattner26824902007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004434 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004435 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004436 return ExprError();
4437
4438 Cond.release();
4439 LHS.release();
4440 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004441 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004442 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004443 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004444}
4445
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004446// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004447// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004448// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4449// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4450// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004451Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004452Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4453 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004454
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004455 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4456 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4457 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4458 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4459 return Compatible;
4460 }
4461
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004462 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004463 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4464 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004465
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004466 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004467 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4468 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004469
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004470 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004471
4472 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4473 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4474 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004475 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004476 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004477 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004478
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004479 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4480 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004481 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004482 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004483 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004484 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004485
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004486 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004487 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4488 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004489 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004490
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004491 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004492 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004493 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004494
4495 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004496 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4497 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004498 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004499 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004500 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004501 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4502 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4503 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4504 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4505 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4506 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004507 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004508 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004509 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004510 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004511
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004512 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004513 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004514 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004515 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004516
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004517 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4518 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4519 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4520 // warning can be disabled.
4521 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4522 return ConvTy;
4523 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4524 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004525
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004526 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4527 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4528 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4529 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4530 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4531 do {
4532 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4533 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004534
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004535 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4536 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4537 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004538
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004539 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004540 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004541 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004542
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004543 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004544 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004545 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004546 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004547}
4548
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004549/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4550/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4551/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4552// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004553Sema::AssignConvertType
4554Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004555 QualType rhsType) {
4556 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004557
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004558 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004559 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4560 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004561
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004562 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4563 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4564 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004565
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004566 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004567
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004568 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004569 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004570 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004571
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004572 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4573 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4574 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4575 }
4576 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004577 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004578 return ConvTy;
4579}
4580
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004581/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4582/// for assignment compatibility.
4583Sema::AssignConvertType
4584Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004585 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4586 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004587 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4588 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004589 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004590 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004591 }
4592 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4593 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004594 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4595 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004596 return IncompatiblePointer;
4597 return Compatible;
4598 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004599 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004600 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004601 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004602 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4603 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4604 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4605 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4606 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4607 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004608
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004609 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4610 return Compatible;
4611 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4612 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004613 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004614}
4615
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004616/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4617/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004618/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4619///
4620/// int a, *pint;
4621/// short *pshort;
4622/// struct foo *pfoo;
4623///
4624/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4625/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4626/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4627/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4628///
4629/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004630/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004631///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004632Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004633Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004634 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4635 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004636 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4637 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004638
4639 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004640 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004641
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004642 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4643 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4644 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4645 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4646 return Compatible;
4647 }
4648
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004649 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4650 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4651 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4652 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4653 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4654 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4655 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004656 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004657 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004658 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004659 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004660 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004661 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4662 // to the same ExtVector type.
4663 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4664 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4665 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004666 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004667 return Compatible;
4668 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004669
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004670 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004671 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004672 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004673 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004674 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4675 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004676 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004677 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004678 }
4679 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004680 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004681
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004682 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4683 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004684 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004685
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004686 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004687 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004688 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004689
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004690 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004691 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004692
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004693 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004694 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004695 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4696 return Compatible;
4697 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004698 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004699 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4700 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004701 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004702
4703 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004704 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004705 return Compatible;
4706 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004707 return Incompatible;
4708 }
4709
4710 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4711 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004712 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004713
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004714 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004715 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004716 return Compatible;
4717
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004718 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4719 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004720
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004721 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004722 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004723 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004724 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004725 return Incompatible;
4726 }
4727
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004728 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4729 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4730 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004731
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004732 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004733 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004734 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4735 return Compatible;
4736 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004737 }
4738 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004739 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004740 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004741 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004742 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4743 return Compatible;
4744 }
4745 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4746 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4747 return Compatible;
4748 return Incompatible;
4749 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004750 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004751 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004752 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4753 return Compatible;
4754
4755 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004756 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004757
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004758 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004759 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004760
4761 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004762 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004763 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004764 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004765 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004766 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4767 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4768 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4769 return Compatible;
4770
4771 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4772 return PointerToInt;
4773
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004774 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004775 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004776 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4777 return Compatible;
4778 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004779 }
4780 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004781 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004782 return Compatible;
4783 return Incompatible;
4784 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004785
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004786 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004787 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004788 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004789 }
4790 return Incompatible;
4791}
4792
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004793/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4794/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004795static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004796 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4797 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4798 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004799 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004800 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004801 SourceLocation());
4802 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4803 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4804
4805 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4806 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004807 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004808 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004809 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004810}
4811
4812Sema::AssignConvertType
4813Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4814 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4815
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004816 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004817 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4818 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004819 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004820 return Incompatible;
4821
4822 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4823 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4824 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4825 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004826 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4827 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004828 it != itend; ++it) {
4829 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4830 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4831 // 1) void pointer
4832 // 2) null pointer constant
4833 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004834 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004835 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004836 InitField = *it;
4837 break;
4838 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004839
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004840 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004841 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004842 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004843 InitField = *it;
4844 break;
4845 }
4846 }
4847
4848 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4849 == Compatible) {
4850 InitField = *it;
4851 break;
4852 }
4853 }
4854
4855 if (!InitField)
4856 return Incompatible;
4857
4858 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4859 return Compatible;
4860}
4861
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004862Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004863Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004864 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4865 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4866 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4867 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4868 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004869 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004870 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004871 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004872 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004873 }
4874
4875 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4876 // structures.
4877 }
4878
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004879 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4880 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004881 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4882 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004883 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004884 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004885 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004886 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004887 return Compatible;
4888 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004889
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004890 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004891 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004892 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004893 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004894 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004895 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004896 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004897 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004898
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004899 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4900 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004901
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004902 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4903 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004904 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4905 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4906 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4907 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004908 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004909 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004910 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004911 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004912}
4913
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004914QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004915 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004916 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004917 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004918 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004919}
4920
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004921QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004922 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004923 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004924 QualType lhsType =
4925 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4926 QualType rhsType =
4927 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004928
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004929 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004930 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004931 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004932
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004933 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4934 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004935 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4936 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004937 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4938 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004939 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004940 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004941 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4942 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4943 return lhsType;
4944 }
4945
4946 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4947 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004948 }
4949 }
4950 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004951
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004952 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4953 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4954 bool swapped = false;
4955 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4956 swapped = true;
4957 std::swap(rex, lex);
4958 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4959 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004960
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004961 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004962 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004963 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004964 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004965 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004966 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004967 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4968 return lhsType;
4969 }
4970 }
4971 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4972 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4973 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004974 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004975 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4976 return lhsType;
4977 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004978 }
4979 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004980
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004981 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004982 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004983 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004984 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004985 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004986}
4987
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004988QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4989 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004990 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004991 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004992
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004993 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004994
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004995 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4996 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4997 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004998
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004999 // Check for division by zero.
5000 if (isDiv &&
5001 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005002 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005003 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005004
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005005 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005006}
5007
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005008QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005009 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005010 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5011 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5012 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5013 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5014 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005015
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005016 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005017
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005018 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5019 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005020
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005021 // Check for remainder by zero.
5022 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005023 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5024 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005025
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005026 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005027}
5028
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005029QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005030 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005031 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5032 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5033 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5034 return compType;
5035 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005036
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005037 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005038
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005039 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005040 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5041 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5042 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005043 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005044 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005045
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005046 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5047 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005048 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005049 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5050
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005051 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005052
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005053 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005054 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005055
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005056 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5057 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005058 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5059 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005060 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005061 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005062 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005063
5064 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5065 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5066 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005067 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005068 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5069 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5070 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5071 return QualType();
5072 }
5073
5074 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5075 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5076 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005077 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005078 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005079 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005080 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005081 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5082 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005083 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5084 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005085 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005086 return QualType();
5087 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005088 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005089 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005090 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5091 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5092 return QualType();
5093 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005094
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005095 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005096 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5097 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5098 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5099 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5100 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005101 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005102 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5103 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005104 return PExp->getType();
5105 }
5106 }
5107
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005108 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005109}
5110
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005111// C99 6.5.6
5112QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005113 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5114 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5115 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5116 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5117 return compType;
5118 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005119
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005120 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005121
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005122 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005123
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005124 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005125 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5126 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005127 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005128 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005129 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005130
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005131 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005132 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005133 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005134
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005135 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005136
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005137 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5138 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5139 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5140 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5141 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5142 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5143 return QualType();
5144 }
5145
5146 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5147 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5148 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5149 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5150 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005151 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005152 return QualType();
5153 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005154
5155 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5156 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5157 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005158 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005159 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005160 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005161 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005162 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005163
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005164 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005165 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005166 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5167 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5168 return QualType();
5169 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005170
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005171 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005172 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5173 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5174 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5175 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5176 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5177 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005178 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005179 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5180
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005181 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005182 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005183 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005184
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005185 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005186 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005187 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005188
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005189 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5190 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5191 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5192 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5193 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5194 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5195 return QualType();
5196 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005197
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005198 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5199 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5200 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5201 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005202 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005203 return QualType();
5204 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005205
5206 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5207 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5208 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5209 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5210 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005211 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5212 << rex->getSourceRange()
5213 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005214 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005215
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005216 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5217 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5218 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5219 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5220 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5221 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5222 return QualType();
5223 }
5224 } else {
5225 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5226 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5227 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5228 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5229 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5230 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5231 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5232 return QualType();
5233 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005234 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005235
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005236 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5237 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5238 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5239 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5240 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005241 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005242 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005243
5244 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005245 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5246 }
5247 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005248
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005249 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005250}
5251
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005252// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005253QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005254 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005255 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5256 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005257 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005258
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005259 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5260 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5261 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5262
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005263 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5264 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005265 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5266 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5267 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5268 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5269 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005270 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005271 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005272 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005273
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005274 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005275
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005276 // Sanity-check shift operands
5277 llvm::APSInt Right;
5278 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005279 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5280 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005281 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005282 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5283 else {
5284 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5285 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5286 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5287 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5288 }
5289 }
5290
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005291 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005292 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005293}
5294
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005295static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5296 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5297 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5298 return true;
5299 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5300 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5301 }
5302 return false;
5303}
5304
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005305// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005306QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005307 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5308 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5309
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005310 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005311 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005312 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005313
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005314 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5315 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005316
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005317 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5318 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005319 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5320 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5321 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005322 //
5323 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5324 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5325 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5326 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5327 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5328 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005329 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5330 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005331 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005332 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005333 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005334 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005335 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5336 << 0 // self-
5337 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5338 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5339 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5340 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5341 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5342 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5343 // what is it always going to eval to?
5344 char always_evals_to;
5345 switch(Opc) {
5346 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5347 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5348 break;
5349 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5350 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5351 break;
5352 default:
5353 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5354 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5355 break;
5356 }
5357 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5358 << 1 // array
5359 << always_evals_to);
5360 }
5361 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005362 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005363
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005364 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5365 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5366 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5367 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005368
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005369 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5370 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005371 Expr *literalString = 0;
5372 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005373 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005374 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005375 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005376 literalString = lex;
5377 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005378 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5379 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005380 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005381 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005382 literalString = rex;
5383 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5384 }
5385
5386 if (literalString) {
5387 std::string resultComparison;
5388 switch (Opc) {
5389 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5390 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5391 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5392 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5393 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5394 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5395 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5396 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005397
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005398 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5399 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5400 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005401 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005402 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005403 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005404
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005405 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5406 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5407 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5408 else {
5409 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5410 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5411 }
5412
5413 lType = lex->getType();
5414 rType = rex->getType();
5415
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005416 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005417 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005418
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005419 if (isRelational) {
5420 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005421 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005422 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005423 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005424 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005425 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005426
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005427 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005428 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005429 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005430
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005431 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005432 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005433 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005434 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005435
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005436 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5437 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005438 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005439 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005440 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005441 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005442 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005443
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005444 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005445 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5446 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005447 if (!isRelational &&
5448 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5449 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5450 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005451 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5452 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005453 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5454 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005455 Diag(Loc,
5456 isSFINAEContext()?
5457 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5458 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005459 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005460
5461 if (isSFINAEContext())
5462 return QualType();
5463
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005464 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5465 return ResultTy;
5466 }
5467 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005468 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5469 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5470 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5471 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5472 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5473 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005474 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005475 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005476 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005477 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005478 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005479 if (T.isNull()) {
5480 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5481 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5482 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005483 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005484 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005485 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005486 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005487 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005488 }
5489
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005490 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5491 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005492 return ResultTy;
5493 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005494 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5495 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5496 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5497 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5498 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5499 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5500 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5501 }
5502 } else if (!isRelational &&
5503 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5504 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5505 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5506 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5507 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5508 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5509 }
5510 } else {
5511 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005512 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005513 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005514 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005515 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005516 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005517 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005518 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005519
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005520 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005521 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005522 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005523 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005524 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5525 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005526 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005527 return ResultTy;
5528 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005529 if (LHSIsNull &&
5530 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5531 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005532 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005533 return ResultTy;
5534 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005535
5536 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005537 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005538 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5539 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005540 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5541 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5542 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5543 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5544 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5545 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5546 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5547 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005548 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005549 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005550 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005551 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005552 if (T.isNull()) {
5553 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005554 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005555 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005556 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005557 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005558 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005559 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005560 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005561 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005562
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005563 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5564 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005565 return ResultTy;
5566 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005567
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005568 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005569 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5570 return ResultTy;
5571 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005572
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005573 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005574 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005575 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5576 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005577
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005578 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005579 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005580 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005581 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005582 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005583 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005584 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005585 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005586 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005587 if (!isRelational
5588 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5589 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005590 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005591 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005592 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005593 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005594 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5595 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5596 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005597 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005598 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005599 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005600 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005601
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005602 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005603 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005604 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5605 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005606 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005607 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005608 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005609 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005610
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005611 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5612 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005613 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005614 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005615 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005616 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005617 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005618 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005619 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005620 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005621 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5622 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005623 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005624 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005625 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005626 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005627 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5628 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005629 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005630 bool isError = false;
5631 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5632 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5633 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005634 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005635 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005636 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005637 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5638 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5639 isError = true;
5640 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005641 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005642
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005643 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005644 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005645 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005646 if (isError)
5647 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005648 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005649
5650 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5651 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005652 else
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005653 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005654 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005655 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005656
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005657 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005658 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5659 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005660 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005661 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005662 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005663 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5664 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005665 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005666 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005667 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005668 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005669}
5670
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005671/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005672/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005673/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5674/// types.
5675QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005676 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005677 bool isRelational) {
5678 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5679 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005680 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005681 if (vType.isNull())
5682 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005683
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005684 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5685 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005686
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005687 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5688 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5689 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005690 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005691 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5692 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5693 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005694 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5695 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5696 << 0 // self-
5697 << 2 // "a constant"
5698 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005699 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005700
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005701 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005702 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5703 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005704 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005705 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005706
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005707 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5708 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5709 // elements for floating point vectors.
5710 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5711 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005712
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005713 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005714 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005715 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005716 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005717 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005718 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5719
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005720 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005721 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005722 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5723}
5724
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005725inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005726 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff3e5e5562007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005727 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005728 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005729
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005730 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005731
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005732 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005733 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005734 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005735}
5736
5737inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005738 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5739
5740 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5741 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5742 // is a constant.
5743 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
5744 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->isEvaluatable(Context) &&
5745 !Loc.isMacroID())
5746 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5747 << rex->getSourceRange()
5748 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5749 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&" : "|");
5750
5751
5752
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005753 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5754 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5755 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005756
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005757 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5758 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005759
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005760 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005761 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005762
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005763 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5764 // non-overloadable operands.
5765
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005766 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5767 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005768 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5769 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5770 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005771 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005772
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005773 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5774 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5775 // The result is a bool.
5776 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005777}
5778
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005779/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5780/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5781/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5782///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005783static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005784 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5785 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5786 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5787 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005788 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005789 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5790 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5791 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5792 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005793 }
5794 }
5795 return false;
5796}
5797
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005798/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5799/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5800static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005801 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005802 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005803 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005804 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5805 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005806 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5807 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005808
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005809 unsigned Diag = 0;
5810 bool NeedType = false;
5811 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005812 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005813 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005814 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5815 NeedType = true;
5816 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005817 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005818 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5819 NeedType = true;
5820 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005821 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005822 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5823 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005824 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5825 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005826 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005827 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5828 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005829 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5830 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005831 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5832 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005833 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005834 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005835 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005836 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005837 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5838 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005839 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005840 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5841 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005842 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5843 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5844 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005845 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5846 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5847 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005848 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5849 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5850 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005851 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005852
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005853 SourceRange Assign;
5854 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5855 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005856 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005857 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005858 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005859 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005860 return true;
5861}
5862
5863
5864
5865// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005866QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5867 SourceLocation Loc,
5868 QualType CompoundType) {
5869 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5870 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005871 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005872
5873 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5874 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005875 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005876 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005877 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005878 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005879 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5880 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5881 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5882 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5883 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5884 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5885 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5886 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5887 }
5888 }
5889
5890 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005891 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5892 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5893 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005894 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005895 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005896 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005897 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005898
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005899 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5900 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5901 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005902 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005903 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5904 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5905 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5906 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5907 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005908 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005909 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005910 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5911 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5912 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005913 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5914 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005915 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5916 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5917 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005918 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005919 }
5920 } else {
5921 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005922 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005923 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005924
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005925 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005926 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005927 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005928
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00005929
5930 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
5931 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
5932 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
5933 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
5934 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
5935 // check.
5936 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
5937 if (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref &&
5938 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
5939 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
5940 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
5941 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
5942 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
5943 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
5944 }
5945
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005946 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5947 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005948 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005949 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5950 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005951 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005952 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005953 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005954}
5955
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005956// C99 6.5.17
5957QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00005958 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
5959
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005960 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005961 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5962 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5963 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005964
5965 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5966 // incomplete in C++).
5967
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005968 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005969}
5970
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005971/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5972/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005973QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005974 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005975 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5976 return Context.DependentTy;
5977
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005978 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5979 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005980
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005981 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5982 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5983 if (!isInc) {
5984 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5985 return QualType();
5986 }
5987 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5988 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5989 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005990 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005991 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5992 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005993
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005994 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005995 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005996 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5997 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5998 << Op->getSourceRange();
5999 return QualType();
6000 }
6001
6002 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006003 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006004 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006005 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6006 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6007 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6008 return QualType();
6009 }
6010
6011 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006012 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006013 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006014 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006015 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006016 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006017 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006018 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006019 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006020 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6021 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6022 return QualType();
6023 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006024 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006025 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6026 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006027 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006028 } else {
6029 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006030 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006031 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006032 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006033 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006034 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006035 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006036 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006037 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6038 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6039 // operand.
6040 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6041 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006042}
6043
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006044/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006045/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006046/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6047/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6048/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6049/// - &(x) => x
6050/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6051/// - &s.xx => s
6052/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6053/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6054/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6055/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006056static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006057 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006058 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006059 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006060 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006061 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6062 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6063 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006064 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006065 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006066 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006067 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006068 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006069 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6070 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006071 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6072 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6073 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6074 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6075 }
6076 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006077 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006078 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6079 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006080
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006081 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006082 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6083 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6084 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6085 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6086 default:
6087 return 0;
6088 }
6089 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006090 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006091 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006092 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006093 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6094 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006095 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006096 default:
6097 return 0;
6098 }
6099}
6100
6101/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006102/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006103/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006104/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006105/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006106/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006107/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006108QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006109 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6110 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6111
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006112 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6113 return Context.DependentTy;
6114
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006115 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6116 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6117 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6118 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6119 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6120 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6121 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6122 }
6123 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6124 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6125 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006126 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006127 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006128
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006129 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6130 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6131 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6132 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6133 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6134 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6135 // branch of the if, below.
6136 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6137 << dcl;
6138 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6139
6140 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6141 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6142 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6143 .getTypePtr());
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006144 }
6145
6146 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006147 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6148 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6149 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6150 if (isSFINAEContext())
6151 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerc721ae82010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006152 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op))
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006153 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Chris Lattnerc721ae82010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006154 else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006155 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006156 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006157 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006158 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006159 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6160 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006161 return QualType();
6162 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006163 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006164 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6165 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6166 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006167 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006168 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006169 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006170 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006171 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006172 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006173 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6174 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6175 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6176 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6177 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006178 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6179 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006180 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6181 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006182 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6183 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006184 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006185 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006186 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6187 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
6188 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006189 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6190 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006191 return QualType();
6192 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006193 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006194 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006195 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006196 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006197 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6198 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006199 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006200 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006201 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6202 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006203 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006204 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6205 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6206 return QualType();
6207 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006208
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006209 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6210 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006211 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006212 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006213 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes6fea8d22008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006214 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006215 // As above.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006216 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6217 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006218 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6219 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6220 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006221 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006222 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006223
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006224 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6225 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6226 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6227 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6228 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6229 }
6230
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006231 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
6232 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6233}
6234
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006235/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006236QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006237 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6238 return Context.DependentTy;
6239
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006240 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006241 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6242 QualType Result;
6243
6244 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6245 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6246 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6247 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6248 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6249 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6250 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6251 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6252 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006253
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006254 if (Result.isNull()) {
6255 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6256 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6257 return QualType();
6258 }
6259
6260 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006261}
6262
6263static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6264 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6265 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6266 switch (Kind) {
6267 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006268 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6269 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006270 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6271 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6272 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6273 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6274 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6275 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6276 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6277 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6278 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6279 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6280 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6281 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6282 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6283 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6284 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6285 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6286 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6287 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6288 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6289 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6290 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6291 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6292 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6293 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6294 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6295 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6296 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6297 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6298 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6299 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6300 }
6301 return Opc;
6302}
6303
6304static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6305 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6306 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6307 switch (Kind) {
6308 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6309 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6310 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6311 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6312 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6313 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6314 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6315 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6316 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006317 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6318 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
6319 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
6320 }
6321 return Opc;
6322}
6323
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006324/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6325/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6326/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006327Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6328 unsigned Op,
6329 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006330 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006331 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006332 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6333 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6334 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006335
6336 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006337 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6338 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6339 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006340 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6341 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6342 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6343 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6344 break;
6345 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006346 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006347 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6348 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006349 break;
6350 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6351 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6352 break;
6353 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6354 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6355 break;
6356 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6357 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6358 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006359 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006360 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6361 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6362 break;
6363 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6364 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6365 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6366 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006367 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006368 break;
6369 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6370 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006371 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006372 break;
6373 case BinaryOperator::And:
6374 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6375 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6376 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6377 break;
6378 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6379 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006380 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006381 break;
6382 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6383 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006384 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6385 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006386 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6387 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6388 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006389 break;
6390 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006391 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6392 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6393 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6394 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006395 break;
6396 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006397 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6398 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6399 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006400 break;
6401 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006402 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6403 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6404 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006405 break;
6406 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6407 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006408 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6409 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6410 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6411 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006412 break;
6413 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6414 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6415 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006416 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6417 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6418 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6419 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006420 break;
6421 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6422 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6423 break;
6424 }
6425 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006426 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006427 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006428 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6429 else
6430 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006431 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6432 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006433}
6434
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006435/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6436/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006437static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6438 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006439 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6440 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6441 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006442 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006443 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6444
6445 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6446 return;
6447
6448 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6449 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6450 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006451 return;
6452 }
6453
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006454 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6455 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006456 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006457
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006458 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006459 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006460
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006461 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6462 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6463 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6464 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006465 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006466 return;
6467 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006468
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006469 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006470 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6471 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006472}
6473
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006474/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6475/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6476/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6477/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006478static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6479 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006480 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6481 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6482 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6483 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006484 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006485 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006486 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6487
6488 // Subs are not binary operators.
6489 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6490 return;
6491
6492 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6493 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006494 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6495 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006496 return;
6497
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006498 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006499 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006500 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006501 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6502 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006503 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006504 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006505 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6506 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6507 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6508 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006509 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006510 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006511 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006512 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6513 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006514 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006515 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006516 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6517 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6518 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6519 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006520}
6521
6522/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6523/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6524/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6525static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6526 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006527 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006528 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6529}
6530
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006531// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006532Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6533 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6534 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006535 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006536 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006537
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006538 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6539 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006540
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006541 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6542 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6543
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006544 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6545}
6546
6547Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6548 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6549 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006550 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006551 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006552 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6553 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6554 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6555 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6556 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006557 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006558 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006559 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6560 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6561 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006562
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006563 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6564 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006565 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006566 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006567
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006568 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006569 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006570}
6571
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006572Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006573 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006574 ExprArg InputArg) {
6575 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006576
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006577 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006578 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006579 QualType resultType;
6580 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006581 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6582 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6583 break;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006584
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006585 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6586 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006587 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6588 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006589 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006590 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006591 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6592 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6593 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006594 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006595 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006596 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6597 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006598 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006599 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006600 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6601 break;
6602 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6603 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006604 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6605 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006606 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6607 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006608 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6609 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006610 break;
6611 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6612 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6613 break;
6614 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6615 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6616 resultType->isPointerType())
6617 break;
6618
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006619 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6620 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006621 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006622 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6623 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006624 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6625 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006626 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6627 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6628 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006629 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006630 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006631 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006632 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6633 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006634 break;
6635 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
6636 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006637 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006638 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006639 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6640 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006641 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006642 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6643 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006644 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006645 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6646 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006647 break;
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006648 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006649 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006650 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006651 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006652 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006653 resultType = Input->getType();
6654 break;
6655 }
6656 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006657 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006658
6659 InputArg.release();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006660 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006661}
6662
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006663Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6664 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6665 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006666 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006667 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6668 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006669 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6670 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6671 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6672 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006673 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006674 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006675 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6676 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6677 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006678
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006679 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6680 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006681
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006682 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6683}
6684
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006685// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6686Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6687 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6688 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6689}
6690
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006691/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006692Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6693 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6694 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006695 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattnerea29a3a2009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006696 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006697
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006698 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6699 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006700 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006701 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006702
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006703 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006704 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6705 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006706}
6707
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006708Sema::OwningExprResult
6709Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6710 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6711 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006712 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6713 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6714
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006715 bool isFileScope
6716 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006717 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006718 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006719
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006720 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6721 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6722 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006723
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006724 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6725 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6726 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006727
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006728 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6729 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6730 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6731 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6732 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006733
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006734 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006735 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006736 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006737
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006738 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6739 // expressions are not lvalues.
6740
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006741 substmt.release();
6742 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006743}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006744
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006745Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6746 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006747 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6748 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006749 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6750 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006751 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006752 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006753
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006754 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6755 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6756 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006757 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006758 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6759 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6760
6761 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6762 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6763 if (!Dependent
6764 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6765 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6766 << TypeRange))
6767 return ExprError();
6768
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006769 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6770 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006771 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6772 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006773 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006774 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6775 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006776
6777 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6778 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6779 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6780 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6781 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6782 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6783 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6784 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6785 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6786 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6787 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6788 if(!AT)
6789 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6790 << CurrentType);
6791 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6792 } else
6793 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6794
6795 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6796 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6797 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6798 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6799 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6800 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6801 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6802 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6803
6804 // Record this array index.
6805 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6806 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6807 continue;
6808 }
6809
6810 // Offset of a field.
6811 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6812 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6813 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6814 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6815 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6816 continue;
6817 }
6818
6819 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6820 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6821 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6822 return ExprError();
6823
6824 // Look for the designated field.
6825 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6826 if (!RC)
6827 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6828 << CurrentType);
6829 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6830
6831 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6832 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6833 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6834 // (clause 9).
6835 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6836 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6837 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6838 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6839 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6840 << CurrentType))
6841 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6842 }
6843
6844 // Look for the field.
6845 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6846 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6847 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6848 if (!MemberDecl)
6849 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6850 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6851 OC.LocEnd));
6852
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006853 // C99 7.17p3:
6854 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6855 //
6856 // We diagnose this as an error.
6857 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6858 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6859 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6860 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6861 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6862 return ExprError();
6863 }
6864
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006865 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6866 // the base class indirections.
6867 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6868 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6869 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6870 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6871 Paths)) {
6872 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6873 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6874 B != BEnd; ++B)
6875 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6876 }
6877
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006878 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006879 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006880 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6881 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6882 unsigned n = Path.size();
6883 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6884 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6885 } else {
6886 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6887 }
6888 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6889 }
6890
6891 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6892 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6893 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6894}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006895
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006896Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6897 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6898 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6899 TypeTy *argty,
6900 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6901 unsigned NumComponents,
6902 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6903
6904 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6905 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6906 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6907 return ExprError();
6908
6909 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6910 if (!ArgTInfo)
6911 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6912
6913 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6914 RPLoc);
6915 }
6916
6917 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6918 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6919
6920 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6921
6922 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6923 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6924 // a struct/union/class.
6925 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6926 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6927
6928 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6929 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6930
6931 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6932 // the offsetof designators.
6933 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6934 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6935 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6936 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6937
6938 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6939 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6940 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6941 // a system header!
6942 if (NumComponents != 1)
6943 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6944 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6945
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006946 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedmanc0d600c2009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006947 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006948
John McCalld00f2002009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006949 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6950 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6951 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006952
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006953 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6954 // leaks like a sieve.
6955 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6956 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6957 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6958 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6959 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6960 if (!AT) {
6961 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006962 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006963 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006964 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006965
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006966 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006967
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006968 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6969 // expression.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006970 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006971
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006972 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6973 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006974 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006975 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006976 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006977 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006978 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6979
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006980 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6981 OC.LocEnd);
6982 continue;
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006983 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006984
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006985 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006986 if (!RC) {
6987 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006988 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006989 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006990 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006991
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006992 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6993 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006994 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006995 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6996 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6997 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006998 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6999 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007000 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00007001 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007002
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00007003 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7004 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007005
John McCall1bcee0a2009-12-02 08:25:40 +00007006 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007007 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007008 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregor3f093272009-10-13 21:16:44 +00007009 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007010 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
7011
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007012 // C99 7.17p3:
7013 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7014 //
7015 // We diagnose this as an error.
7016 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7017 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7018 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7019 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7020 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7021 return ExprError();
7022 }
7023
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007024 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
7025 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007026 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00007027 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007028 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007029 } else {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007030 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
7031 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007032 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
7033 // doesn't matter here.
7034 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007035 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007036 }
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007037 }
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007038 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007039
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007040 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
7041 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007042}
7043
7044
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007045Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7046 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
7047 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007048 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
7049 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
7050 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007051
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007052 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007053
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007054 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7055 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7056 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7057 return ExprError();
7058 }
7059
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007060 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
7061 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007062}
7063
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007064Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7065 ExprArg cond,
7066 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
7067 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7068 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
7069 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
7070 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007071
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007072 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7073
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007074 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007075 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007076 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007077 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007078 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007079 } else {
7080 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7081 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7082 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7083 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007084 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7085 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7086 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007087
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007088 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7089 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007090 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7091 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007092 }
7093
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007094 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7095 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007096 resType, RPLoc,
7097 resType->isDependentType(),
7098 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007099}
7100
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007101//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7102// Clang Extensions.
7103//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7104
7105/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007106void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007107 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7108 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7109 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007110 if (BlockScope)
7111 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7112 else
7113 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007114}
7115
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007116void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007117 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007118 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007119
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007120 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007121 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007122 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007123
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007124 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007125 QualType RetTy;
7126 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007127 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007128 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007129 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007130 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7131 } else {
7132 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007133 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007134 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007135
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007136 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007137
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007138 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7139 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7140 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007141 return;
7142 }
7143
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007144 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7145 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7146 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7147 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7148 return;
7149 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007150
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007151 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007152 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7153 // ^ * { ... }
7154 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007155 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7156 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007157
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007158 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007159 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007160 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7161 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7162 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7163 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007164 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7165 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7166 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7167 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7168 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007169 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007170 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007171
7172 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7173 // ^ fntype { ... }
7174 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7175 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7176 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7177 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7178 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7179 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7180 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007181 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007182 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007183 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007184
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007185 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7186 if (!Params.empty())
7187 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007188
7189 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007190 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007191
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007192 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007193 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7194 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7195 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7196 }
7197
7198 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7199 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007200 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007201 return;
7202
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007203 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7204 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7205
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007206 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007207 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7208 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7209
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007210 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007211 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7212 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7213 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7214
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007215 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007216 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007217 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007218}
7219
7220/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7221/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7222void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007223 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007224 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007225 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007226 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007227}
7228
7229/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7230/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007231Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7232 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007233 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7234 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7235 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007236
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007237 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007238
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007239 PopDeclContext();
7240
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007241 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007242 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7243 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007244
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007245 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007246 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007247
7248 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7249 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7250 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7251
7252 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7253 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7254
7255 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7256 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7257 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7258 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7259
7260 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7261 // preserve its sugar structure.
7262 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7263 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7264 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7265
7266 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7267 } else {
7268 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7269 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7270 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7271 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7272 FPT->isVariadic(),
7273 /*quals*/ 0,
7274 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7275 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7276 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7277 FPT->exception_begin(),
7278 Ext);
7279 }
7280
7281 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7282 } else {
7283 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7284 false, false, 0, 0,
7285 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7286 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007287
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007288 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007289 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7290 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007291 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007292
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007293 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007294 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007295 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007296
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007297 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007298
7299 bool Good = true;
7300 // Check goto/label use.
7301 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7302 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7303 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7304
7305 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7306 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7307 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7308 continue;
7309
7310 // Emit error.
7311 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7312 Good = false;
7313 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007314 if (!Good) {
7315 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007316 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007317 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007318
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007319 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007320 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7321 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7322 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007323
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007324 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7325 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007326 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007327 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007328}
7329
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007330Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7331 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7332 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007333 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007334 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7335 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007336
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007337 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007338
7339 // Get the va_list type
7340 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007341 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7342 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7343 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7344 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007345 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007346 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7347 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7348 } else {
7349 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7350 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007351 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007352 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007353 return ExprError();
7354 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007355
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007356 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7357 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007358 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7359 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007360 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007361 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007362
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007363 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007364 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007365
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007366 expr.release();
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00007367 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E,
7368 T.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007369 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007370}
7371
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007372Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007373 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7374 // pointers on the target.
7375 QualType Ty;
7376 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7377 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7378 else
7379 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7380
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007381 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007382}
7383
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007384static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007385 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007386 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7387 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007388
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007389 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7390 if (!PT)
7391 return;
7392
7393 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7394 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7395 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7396 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7397 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7398 return;
7399 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007400
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007401 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7402 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7403 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7404 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007405
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007406 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007407}
7408
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007409bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7410 SourceLocation Loc,
7411 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007412 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7413 bool *Complained) {
7414 if (Complained)
7415 *Complained = false;
7416
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007417 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7418 bool isInvalid = false;
7419 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007420 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007421
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007422 switch (ConvTy) {
7423 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7424 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007425 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007426 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7427 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007428 case IntToPointer:
7429 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7430 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007431 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007432 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007433 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7434 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007435 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7436 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7437 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007438 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7439 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7440 break;
7441 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007442 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7443 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7444 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7445 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7446 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7447 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7448 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7449 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7450 // C++ semantics.
7451 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7452 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7453 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007454 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7455 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007456 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007457 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007458 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007459 case IntToBlockPointer:
7460 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7461 break;
7462 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007463 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007464 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007465 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007466 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007467 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7468 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7469 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007470 case IncompatibleVectors:
7471 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7472 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007473 case Incompatible:
7474 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7475 isInvalid = true;
7476 break;
7477 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007478
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007479 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7480 switch (Action) {
7481 case AA_Assigning:
7482 case AA_Initializing:
7483 // The destination type comes first.
7484 FirstType = DstType;
7485 SecondType = SrcType;
7486 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007487
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007488 case AA_Returning:
7489 case AA_Passing:
7490 case AA_Converting:
7491 case AA_Sending:
7492 case AA_Casting:
7493 // The source type comes first.
7494 FirstType = SrcType;
7495 SecondType = DstType;
7496 break;
7497 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007498
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007499 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007500 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007501 if (Complained)
7502 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007503 return isInvalid;
7504}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007505
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007506bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007507 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7508 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7509 if (Result)
7510 *Result = ICEResult;
7511 return false;
7512 }
7513
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007514 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7515
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007516 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007517 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7518 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7519
7520 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7521 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7522 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7523 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7524 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7525 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7526 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007527
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007528 return true;
7529 }
7530
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007531 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7532 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007533
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007534 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7535 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7536 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007537
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007538 if (Result)
7539 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7540 return false;
7541}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007542
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007543void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007544Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007545 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7546 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007547}
7548
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007549void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007550Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7551 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7552 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7553 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007554
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007555 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7556 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7557 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7558 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7559 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007560 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007561 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7562 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7563 I != IEnd; ++I)
7564 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7565 }
7566
7567 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7568 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7569 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7570 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7571 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7572 I != IEnd; ++I)
7573 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7574 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007575 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007576
7577 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7578 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7579 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7580 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007581 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007582 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7583 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7584 ExprTemporaries.end());
7585
7586 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7587 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007588}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007589
7590/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7591///
7592/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7593/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7594/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7595/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7596///
7597/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7598///
7599/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7600void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7601 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007602
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007603 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007604 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007605
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007606 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7607 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7608 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7609 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007610 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007611 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007612 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007613 return;
7614 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007615
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007616 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7617 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007618
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007619 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7620 // an instantiation.
7621 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7622 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007623
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007624 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007625 case Unevaluated:
7626 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7627 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007628
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007629 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7630 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7631 // "used"; handle this below.
7632 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007633
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007634 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7635 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7636 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7637 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007638 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007639 return;
7640 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007641
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007642 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007643 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007644 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007645 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007646 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007647 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007648 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007649 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007650 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007651 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7652 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007653
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007654 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007655 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007656 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007657 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007658 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7659 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007660 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7661 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7662 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007663 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007664 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007665 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7666 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007667 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007668 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007669 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007670 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007671 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007672 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7673 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7674 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7675 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7676 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007677 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007678 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007679 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007680 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007681 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7682 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7683 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007684 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007685 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007686 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7687 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007688
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007689 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7690 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7691 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7692 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7693 Loc));
7694 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007695 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007696 Loc));
7697 }
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007698 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007699
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007700 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007701 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007702
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007703 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007704 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007705
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007706 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007707 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007708 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007709 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7710 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7711 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7712 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7713 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7714 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7715 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7716 }
7717 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007718
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007719 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007720
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007721 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007722 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007723 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007724}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007725
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007726namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007727 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007728 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007729 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007730 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7731 Sema &S;
7732 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007733
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007734 public:
7735 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007736
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007737 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007738
7739 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7740 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007741 };
7742}
7743
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007744bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7745 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007746 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7747 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7748 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007749
7750 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007751}
7752
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007753bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007754 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7755 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7756 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007757 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7758 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007759 }
7760
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007761 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007762}
7763
7764void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7765 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007766 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007767}
7768
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007769/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7770/// of the program being compiled.
7771///
7772/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007773/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007774/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7775/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7776/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7777/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007778/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007779/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007780///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007781/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7782/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7783/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7784/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007785bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007786 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7787 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7788 case Unevaluated:
7789 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7790 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007791
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007792 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7793 Diag(Loc, PD);
7794 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007795
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007796 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7797 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7798 break;
7799 }
7800
7801 return false;
7802}
7803
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007804bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7805 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7806 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7807 return false;
7808
7809 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7810 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7811 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7812 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007813
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007814 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007815 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007816 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7817 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007818 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007819 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7820 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7821 return true;
7822
7823 return false;
7824}
7825
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007826// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7827// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7828void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7829 SourceLocation Loc;
7830
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007831 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7832
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007833 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7834 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7835 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7836 return;
7837
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007838 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7839 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7840 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7841 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7842
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007843 // self = [<foo> init...]
7844 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7845 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7846 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7847
7848 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7849 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7850 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7851 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7852 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007853
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007854 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7855 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7856 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7857 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7858 return;
7859
7860 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7861 } else {
7862 // Not an assignment.
7863 return;
7864 }
7865
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007866 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007867 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007868
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007869 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007870 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007871 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007872 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7873 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7874 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007875}
7876
7877bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7878 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7879
7880 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007881 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007882
7883 QualType T = E->getType();
7884
7885 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7886 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7887 return true;
7888 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7889 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7890 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7891 return true;
7892 }
7893 }
7894
7895 return false;
7896}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007897
7898Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7899 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007900 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7901 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007902 return ExprError();
7903
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007904 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7905 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7906 return ExprError();
7907 }
7908
7909 return Owned(Sub);
7910}